blob: 0c150ffeed5595ef29b7cde137d05fffd28c194e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
680/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
681///
682/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
683/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
684/// found template arguments.
685static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
686 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
687 TemplateName TName =
688 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
689
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000690 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
691 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000692 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
693 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
694 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000695 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000696
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000697 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000698}
699
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000700/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
701/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
702/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000703static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000704 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
705 return false;
706
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000707 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
708 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
709 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
710 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
711 if (!BaseRT) return false;
712
713 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000714 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000715 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
716 return false;
717 }
718
719 return true;
720}
721
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000722/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
723/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
724static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000725 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000726
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000727 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
728 if (!DC) return true;
729
730 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
731 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
732
733 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
734 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
735
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000736 return false;
737}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000738
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
740/// the prospective base classes.
741static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
742 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
743 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745 return false;
746
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000747 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000748 if (!RD) return false;
749 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
750
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
752 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
753 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
754 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
755 if (!BaseRT) return false;
756
757 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
759 return false;
760 }
761
762 return true;
763}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765enum IMAKind {
766 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
767 IMA_Static,
768
769 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
770 IMA_Mixed,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
774 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
775
776 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
777 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
778 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
779
780 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
781 IMA_Instance,
782
783 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
784 IMA_Unresolved,
785
786 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
789
790 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
791 /// non-class context.
792 IMA_AnonymousMember,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
795 /// context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
797
798 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
799 /// class.
800 IMA_Error_Unrelated
801};
802
803/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
804/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
805/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
806/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
807/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
808/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
809static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
810 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000811 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000812
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000813 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000814 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000815 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
816 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000817
818 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
819 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
820
821 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
822 bool hasNonInstance = false;
823 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
824 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000825 NamedDecl *D = *I;
826 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
828
829 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
830 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
831 // that's a special case.
832 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
833 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
834 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
835 }
836 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
837 }
838 else
839 hasNonInstance = true;
840 }
841
842 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
843 // member reference.
844 if (Classes.empty())
845 return IMA_Static;
846
847 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
848 // an implicit member reference.
849 if (isStaticContext)
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
851
852 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
853 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
854 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
855 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000856 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000857 Classes))
858 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
859
860 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
861}
862
863/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
864static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
866 const LookupResult &R) {
867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
868 SourceRange Range(Loc);
869 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
870
871 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
872 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
873 if (MD->isStatic()) {
874 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
875 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
876 << Range << R.getLookupName();
877 return;
878 }
879 }
880
881 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
882 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
883 return;
884 }
885
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000887}
888
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000889/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
890///
891/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000892bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000893 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
895
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
899 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000900 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000901 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
903 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000905 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
906 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
907 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
908 // dependent name.
909 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
910 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000911 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
912 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
913
914 if (!R.empty()) {
915 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
916 R.suppressDiagnostics();
917
918 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
919 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
920 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
921 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
922
923 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
924 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
925 // Actually quite difficult!
926 if (isInstance)
927 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000928 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929 else
930 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
931
932 // Do we really want to note all of these?
933 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
934 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
935
936 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
937 return false;
938 }
939 }
940 }
941
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000942 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000943 DeclarationName Corrected;
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000944 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 if (!R.empty()) {
946 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
947 if (SS.isEmpty())
948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
949 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
950 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
951 else
952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
953 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
954 << SS.getRange()
955 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
956 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
957 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
958 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
959 << ND->getDeclName();
960
961 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
962 return false;
963 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000964
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000965 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
966 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
967 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
968 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
969 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
970 // to recover well anyway.
971 if (SS.isEmpty())
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
973 else
974 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
975 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
976 << SS.getRange();
977
978 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
979 return true;
980 }
981 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000982 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000984 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000986 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000988 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
989 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000990 return true;
991 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000992 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000993 }
994
995 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
996 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
997 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
998 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
999 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1000 << SS.getRange();
1001 return true;
1002 }
1003
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001004 // Give up, we can't recover.
1005 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1006 return true;
1007}
1008
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001009Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001010 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001011 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1012 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1013 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1014 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1015 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1016
1017 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001018 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001019
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001020 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001021
1022 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1023 DeclarationName Name;
1024 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1025 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001026 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1027 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001028
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001029 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001030
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001031 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1032 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001033 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1034 // (note: handled after lookup)
1035 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1036 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1037 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001038 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1039 // names a dependent type.
1040 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1041 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001042 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1043 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1044 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001046 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001047 TemplateArgs);
1048 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001049
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001050 // Perform the required lookup.
1051 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1052 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001053 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1054 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1055 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1056 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1057 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001058 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1059 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1060 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001061 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001062 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1063 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001064
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001065 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1066 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001067 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1068 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001069 if (E.isInvalid())
1070 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001071
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1073 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001074 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001075 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001076
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001077 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1078 return ExprError();
1079
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001080 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1081 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001083
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001085 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1087 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1088 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1089 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1090 }
1091
1092 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1093 // call, diagnose the problem.
1094 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001095 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001096 return ExprError();
1097
1098 assert(!R.empty() &&
1099 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001100
1101 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1102 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001103 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001104 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1105 R.clear();
1106 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1107 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1108 return move(E);
1109 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001110 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001111 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001112
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001113 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1114 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1115
1116 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001117 // Warn about constructs like:
1118 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1119 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001120 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1121 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001122 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001123 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001125 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001126 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001127 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1128 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001129 break;
1130 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001131
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001132 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1133 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001134 }
1135 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001136 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001137 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1138 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1139 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1140 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1141 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1142 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001145
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001146 QualType T = Func->getType();
1147 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001148 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001149 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1150 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001152 }
1153 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001154
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001155 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1156 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1157 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1158 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1159 // class member access expression.
1160 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1161 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001162 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001164 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1165 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001166 }
1167
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (TemplateArgs)
1169 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001170
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1172}
1173
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001174/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1175Sema::OwningExprResult
1176Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1177 LookupResult &R,
1178 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1179 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1180 case IMA_Instance:
1181 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1182
1183 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1184 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1185 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1186 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1187
1188 case IMA_Mixed:
1189 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1190 case IMA_Unresolved:
1191 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1192
1193 case IMA_Static:
1194 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1195 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1196 if (TemplateArgs)
1197 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1198 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1199
1200 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1201 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1202 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1203 return ExprError();
1204 }
1205
1206 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1207 return ExprError();
1208}
1209
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001210/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1211/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1212/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1213/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001214Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001215Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 DeclarationName Name,
1217 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1218 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001219 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1221
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001222 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001223 return ExprError();
1224
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001225 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1226 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1227
1228 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1229 return ExprError();
1230
1231 if (R.empty()) {
1232 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1233 return ExprError();
1234 }
1235
1236 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1237}
1238
1239/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1240/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1241/// additional lookup.
1242///
1243/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1244/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1245///
1246/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1247Sema::OwningExprResult
1248Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001249 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001250 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001251 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001252
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1254 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1255 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1256 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1257 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1258
1259 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1260 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1261 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001262 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001263
1264 bool LookForIvars;
1265 if (Lookup.empty())
1266 LookForIvars = true;
1267 else if (IsClassMethod)
1268 LookForIvars = false;
1269 else
1270 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1271 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001272 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001274 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1276 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1277 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1278 if (IsClassMethod)
1279 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1280 << IV->getDeclName());
1281
1282 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1283 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1284 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1285 return ExprError();
1286
1287 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1288 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1289 return ExprError();
1290
1291 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1292 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1293 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1294 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1295
1296 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1297 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1298 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1299 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001300 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001301 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1302 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1303 SelfName, false, false);
1304 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1305 return Owned(new (Context)
1306 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1307 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1308 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001309 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001310 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001311 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1313 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1314 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1315 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1316 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1317 }
1318 }
1319
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001320 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1321 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1322 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1323 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1324 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1325 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1326 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1327 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1328 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1333 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001334}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001335
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001336/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1337///
1338/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1339///
1340/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1341/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1342/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1343/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1344///
1345/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1346/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1347/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1348/// the class declaring the member.
1349///
1350/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1351/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1352/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001353bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001354Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1355 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001356 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001357 NamedDecl *Member) {
1358 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1359 if (!RD)
1360 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001361
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001362 QualType DestRecordType;
1363 QualType DestType;
1364 QualType FromRecordType;
1365 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1366 bool PointerConversions = false;
1367 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1368 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001369
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001370 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1371 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1372 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1373 PointerConversions = true;
1374 } else {
1375 DestType = DestRecordType;
1376 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001377 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001378 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1379 if (Method->isStatic())
1380 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001381
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001382 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1383 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001384
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001385 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1386 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1387 PointerConversions = true;
1388 } else {
1389 FromRecordType = FromType;
1390 DestType = DestRecordType;
1391 }
1392 } else {
1393 // No conversion necessary.
1394 return false;
1395 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001396
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001397 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1398 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001399
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1401 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1402 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001403
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001404 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1405 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1406
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001407 bool isLvalue
1408 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1409
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001411 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001412 // class name.
1413 //
1414 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1415 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1416 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1417 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1418 //
1419 // class Base { public: int x; };
1420 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1421 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1422 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1423 //
1424 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1425 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1426 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1427 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001428 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001429 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1430 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1431 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1432
1433 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1434
1435 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1436 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1437 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1438 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001439 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001440 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001441 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001442 return true;
1443
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001444 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001445 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001446 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001447 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001448
1449 FromType = QType;
1450 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1451
1452 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1453 // we're done.
1454 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1455 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001456 }
1457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001458
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001460
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001461 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1462 // down to the using declaration's type.
1463 //
1464 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1465 // class ever has member declarations.
1466 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1467 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1468 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1469 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1470
1471 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1472 // conversion is non-trivial.
1473 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1474 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001475 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001476 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001477 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001478 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001479
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001480 QualType UType = URecordType;
1481 if (PointerConversions)
1482 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001483 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001484 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001485 FromType = UType;
1486 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1487 }
1488
1489 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1490 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1491 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001493
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001494 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1495 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1496 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001498 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001500 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001501 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001502 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001503}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001504
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001505/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001506static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001507 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001508 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1509 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001510 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1511 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1512 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001513 if (SS.isSet()) {
1514 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1515 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001516 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001517
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001519 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001520}
1521
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001522/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1523/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1524/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1525/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001526Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1528 LookupResult &R,
1529 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1530 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001531 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1532
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001533 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001534
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001535 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1536 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001537 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001538 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001539 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001540 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001541 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001542
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001543 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1544 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001545 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1546 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001547 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1548 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001549 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1550 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1551 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1552 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001553 }
1554
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001555 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1556 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1557 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001558 SS,
1559 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1560 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001561}
1562
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001563bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001564 const LookupResult &R,
1565 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001566 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1567 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1568 return false;
1569
1570 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001571 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001572 return false;
1573
1574 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001575 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001576 return false;
1577
1578 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1579 // normal lookup:
1580 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1581 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1582
1583 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1584 // -- a declaration of a class member
1585 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1586 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001587 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001588 return false;
1589
1590 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1591 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1592 // using-declaration
1593 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1594 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1595 // turn off ADL anyway).
1596 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1597 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1598 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1599 return false;
1600
1601 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1602 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1603 // template
1604 // And also for builtin functions.
1605 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1606 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1607
1608 // But also builtin functions.
1609 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1610 return false;
1611 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1612 return false;
1613 }
1614
1615 return true;
1616}
1617
1618
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001619/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1620/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1621/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1622/// will in fact be used.
1623static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1624 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1625 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1626 return true;
1627 }
1628
1629 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1630 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1631 return true;
1632 }
1633
1634 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1635 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1636 return true;
1637 }
1638
1639 return false;
1640}
1641
1642Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001644 LookupResult &R,
1645 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001646 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1647 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001648 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001650
1651 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1652 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1653 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001654 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1655 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001656 return ExprError();
1657
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001658 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1659 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1660 // we've picked a target.
1661 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1662
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 bool Dependent
1664 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001665 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001666 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001667 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1668 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001669 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001670 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1671 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001672
1673 return Owned(ULE);
1674}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001675
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001676
1677/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1678Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1681 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001682 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1683 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684
1685 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1686 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001687
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001688 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1689 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1690 // a template argument list.
1691 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1692 << Template << SS.getRange();
1693 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1694 return ExprError();
1695 }
1696
1697 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1698 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1699 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001700 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001701 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001702 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001703 return ExprError();
1704 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001705
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001706 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1707 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1708 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1709 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001710 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001711 return ExprError();
1712
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001713 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1714 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001715 return ExprError();
1716
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001717 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1718 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1719 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1720 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001721 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001722 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1723 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1724 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001725 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001726 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001727 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1728 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1729 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1730 return ExprError();
1731 }
1732
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001733 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001734 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1735 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1736 return ExprError();
1737 }
1738
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001739 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001740 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001741 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001742 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001743 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001744 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1745 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001746 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001747
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001748 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001749 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001750 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001751 }
1752 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1753 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001754
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001755 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001756}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001757
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001758Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1759 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001760 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001761
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001762 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001763 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001764 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1765 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1766 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001767 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001768
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001769 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1770 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001771
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001772 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1773 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001774 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001775 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001776 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001777
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001778 QualType ResTy;
1779 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1780 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1781 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001782 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001783
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001784 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001785 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001786 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1787 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001788 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001789}
1790
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001791Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001792 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001793 bool Invalid = false;
1794 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1795 if (Invalid)
1796 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001798 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1799 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001800 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001802
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001803 QualType Ty;
1804 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1805 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1806 else if (Literal.isWide())
1807 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001808 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1809 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001810 else
1811 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001812
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001813 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1814 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001815 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001816}
1817
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1819 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001820 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1821 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001822 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001823 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001824 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001825 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001826 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001827
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001828 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001829 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1830 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001831 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001832
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001833 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001834 bool Invalid = false;
1835 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1836 if (Invalid)
1837 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001839 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001840 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001841 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842 return ExprError();
1843
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001844 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001845
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001846 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001847 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001848 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001849 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001850 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001851 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001852 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001853 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001854
1855 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1856
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001857 using llvm::APFloat;
1858 APFloat Val(Format);
1859
1860 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001861
1862 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1863 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1864 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1865 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001866 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001867 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001868 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001869 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001870 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1871 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001872 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001873 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1874 }
1875
1876 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1877 << Ty
1878 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1879 }
1880
1881 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001882 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001883
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001884 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001885 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001886 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001887 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001888
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001889 // long long is a C99 feature.
1890 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001891 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001892 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1893
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001894 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001895 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001897 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1898 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1899 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001900 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1901 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001902 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001903 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001904 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1905 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001906
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001907 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1908 // be an unsigned int.
1909 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1910
1911 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001912 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001913 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1914 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001915 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001917 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1918 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1919 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1920 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001921 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001922 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001923 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001924 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001925 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001926 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001928 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001929 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001930 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001932 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1933 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1934 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1935 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001936 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001937 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001938 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001939 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001940 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941 }
1942
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001943 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001944 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001945 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001947 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1948 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1949 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1950 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001951 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001952 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001953 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001954 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001955 }
1956 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1959 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001960 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001964 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001966 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1967 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001968 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001969 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001970 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001972 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1973 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001974 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001975 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
1977 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001978}
1979
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001980Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1981 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001982 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001983 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001984 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001985}
1986
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00001987/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00001988/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001989bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00001990 SourceLocation OpLoc,
1991 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
1992 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001993 if (exprType->isDependentType())
1994 return false;
1995
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001996 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
1997 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
1998 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
1999 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2000 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2001 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2002
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002003 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002004 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002005 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002006 if (isSizeof)
2007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2008 return false;
2009 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002010
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002011 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002012 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2014 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002015 return false;
2016 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002017
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002018 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002019 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2020 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002021 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002022
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002023 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002024 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002026 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2027 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002028 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002029
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002030 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002031}
2032
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002033bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2034 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2035 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002036
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002037 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002038 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2039 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002040
2041 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2042 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2043 return false;
2044
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002045 if (E->getBitField()) {
2046 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2047 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002048 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002049
2050 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2051 // bit-field.
2052 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002053 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002054 return false;
2055
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002056 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2057}
2058
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002059/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002060Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002061Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002062 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002063 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002064 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002065 return ExprError();
2066
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002067 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002068
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002069 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2070 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2071 return ExprError();
2072
2073 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002074 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002075 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2076 R.getEnd()));
2077}
2078
2079/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2080/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002081Action::OwningExprResult
2082Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002083 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2084 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2085 bool isInvalid = false;
2086 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2087 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2088 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2089 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002090 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002091 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2092 isInvalid = true;
2093 } else {
2094 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2095 }
2096
2097 if (isInvalid)
2098 return ExprError();
2099
2100 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2101 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2102 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2103 R.getEnd()));
2104}
2105
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002106/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2107/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2108/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002109Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002110Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2111 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002112 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002113 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002114
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002115 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002116 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2117 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2118 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002119 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002120
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002121 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2122 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2123 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2124
2125 if (Result.isInvalid())
2126 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2127
2128 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002129}
2130
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002131QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002132 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2133 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002134
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002135 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002136 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002137 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002138
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002139 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2140 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2141 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002142
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002143 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002144 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2145 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002146 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002147}
2148
2149
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002150
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002151Action::OwningExprResult
2152Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2153 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002154 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2155 switch (Kind) {
2156 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2157 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2158 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2159 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002160
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002161 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002162}
2163
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002164Action::OwningExprResult
2165Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2166 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002167 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2168 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2169
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002170 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2171 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002172
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002173 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002174 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2175 Base.release();
2176 Idx.release();
2177 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2178 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2179 }
2180
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002181 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002182 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002183 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2184 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2185 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002186 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002187 }
2188
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002189 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2190}
2191
2192
2193Action::OwningExprResult
2194Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2195 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2196 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2197 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2198
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002199 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002200 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2201 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2202 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002203
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002204 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002205
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002206 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002207 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002208 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002209 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002210 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2211 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002212 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2213 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2214 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2215 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002216 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002217 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2218 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002219 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002220 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002221 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002222 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2223 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002224 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002225 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002226 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002227 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2228 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2229 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002230 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002231 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002232 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2233 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2234 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2235 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002236 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002237 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002238 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002239
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002240 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2241 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002242 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2243 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002244 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002245 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2246 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2247 // force the promotion here.
2248 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2249 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002250 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2251 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002252 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2253
2254 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2255 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002256 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002257 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2258 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2259 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2260 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002261 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2262 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002263 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2264
2265 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2266 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002267 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002268 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002269 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2270 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002271 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002272 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002273 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2274 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002275 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2276 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002277
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002278 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002279 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2280 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002281 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2282
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002283 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002284 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2285 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002286 // incomplete types are not object types.
2287 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2288 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2289 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2290 return ExprError();
2291 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002292
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002293 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002294 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002295 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2296 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002297 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002298
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002299 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002300 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002301 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2302 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2303 return ExprError();
2304 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002305
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002306 Base.release();
2307 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002308 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002309 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002310}
2311
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002312QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002313CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002314 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002315 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002316 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2317 // see FIXME there.
2318 //
2319 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2320 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002321 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002322
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002323 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002324 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002325
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002326 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002327 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2328 // to be selected.
2329 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002330
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002331 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2332 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002333 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002334
2335 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2336 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002337 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002338 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2339 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002340 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002341 do
2342 compStr++;
2343 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002344 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002345 do
2346 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002347 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002348 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002349
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002350 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002351 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2352 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002353 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2354 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002355 return QualType();
2356 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002357
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002358 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2359 // operates on.
2360 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002361 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002362
2363 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002364 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002365
2366 while (*compStr) {
2367 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2368 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2369 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2370 return QualType();
2371 }
2372 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002373 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002374
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002375 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002376 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002377 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002378 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002379 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002380 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002381 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002382 if (HexSwizzle)
2383 CompSize--;
2384
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002385 if (CompSize == 1)
2386 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002387
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002388 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002389 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002390 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2391 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2392 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2393 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002394 }
2395 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002396}
2397
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002398static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002399 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002400 const Selector &Sel,
2401 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002402
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002403 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002404 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002405 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002406 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002407
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002408 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2409 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002410 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002411 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002412 return D;
2413 }
2414 return 0;
2415}
2416
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002417static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002418 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002419 const Selector &Sel,
2420 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002421 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2422 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002423 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002424 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002425 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002426 GDecl = PD;
2427 break;
2428 }
2429 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002430 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002431 GDecl = OMD;
2432 break;
2433 }
2434 }
2435 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002436 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002437 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2438 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002439 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002440 if (GDecl)
2441 return GDecl;
2442 }
2443 }
2444 return GDecl;
2445}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002446
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002447Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002448Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2449 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002450 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2451 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2452 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2453 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2454 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2455
2456 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2457 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2458 //
2459 // T* t;
2460 // t.f;
2461 //
2462 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2463 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2464 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2465 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002466 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002467 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2468 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002469 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002470 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002471 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002472 return ExprError();
2473 }
2474 }
2475
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002476 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002477 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002478
2479 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2480 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002481 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002482 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2483 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2484 SS.getRange(),
2485 FirstQualifierInScope,
2486 Name, NameLoc,
2487 TemplateArgs));
2488}
2489
2490/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2491/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2492/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2493static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2494 Expr *BaseExpr,
2495 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002496 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002497 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002498 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2499 // diagnostics.
2500 if (!BaseExpr)
2501 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002502
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002503 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2504 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002505}
2506
2507// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2508// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2509// type. The restriction here is:
2510//
2511// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2512// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2513// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2514//
2515// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2516// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2517// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2518// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2519bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2520 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002521 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002522 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002523 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2524 if (!BaseRT) {
2525 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2526 // dependent.
2527 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2528 return false;
2529 }
2530 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002531
2532 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002533 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2534 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002535 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002536 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002537
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002538 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2539 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2540 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2541 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2542
2543 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2544 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2545
2546 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2547 return false;
2548 }
2549
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002550 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002551 return true;
2552}
2553
2554static bool
2555LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2556 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002557 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002558 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2559 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002560 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002561 << BaseRange))
2562 return true;
2563
2564 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2565 if (SS.isSet()) {
2566 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2567 // nested-name-specifier.
2568 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2569
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002570 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002571 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2572 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2573 return true;
2574 }
2575
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002576 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002577
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002578 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2579 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2580 << DC << SS.getRange();
2581 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002582 }
2583 }
2584
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002585 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2586 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002587
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002588 if (!R.empty())
2589 return false;
2590
2591 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2592 // for typos.
2593 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002594 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002595 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002596 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2597 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2598 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002599 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2600 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002601 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2602 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2603 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002604 return false;
2605 } else {
2606 R.clear();
2607 }
2608
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002609 return false;
2610}
2611
2612Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002613Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002614 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002615 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2617 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2618 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2619 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2620
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002621 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2622 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002623 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002624 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2625 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2626 Name, NameLoc,
2627 TemplateArgs);
2628
2629 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631 // Implicit member accesses.
2632 if (!Base) {
2633 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2634 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2635 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2636 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2637 OpLoc, SS))
2638 return ExprError();
2639
2640 // Explicit member accesses.
2641 } else {
2642 OwningExprResult Result =
2643 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002644 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002645
2646 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2647 Owned(Base);
2648 return ExprError();
2649 }
2650
2651 if (Result.get())
2652 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002653
2654 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2655 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002656 }
2657
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002658 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002659 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2660 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002661}
2662
2663Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002664Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2665 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2666 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002667 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002668 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002669 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2670 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673 if (IsArrow) {
2674 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2675 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2676 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002677 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002678
2679 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2680 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2681 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2682 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2683
2684 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002685 return ExprError();
2686
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 if (R.empty()) {
2688 // Rederive where we looked up.
2689 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2690 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2691 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002692
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002693 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002694 << MemberName << DC
2695 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002696 return ExprError();
2697 }
2698
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002699 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2700 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2701 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2702 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2703 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2704 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2705 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2706 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2707 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2708 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002709 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002710 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002711 return ExprError();
2712
2713 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2714 // result.
2715 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002716 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002717 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002718 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002719 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002720
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002721 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2722 // pick a member.
2723 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2724
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002725 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2726 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2727 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002728 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2729 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002730 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2731 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002732 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002733
2734 return Owned(MemExpr);
2735 }
2736
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002737 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002738 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002739 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2740
2741 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2742
2743 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2744 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2745 // error cases.
2746 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2747 return ExprError();
2748
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002749 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2750 if (!BaseExpr) {
2751 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002752 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002753 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2754
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002755 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2756 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2757 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2758 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002759 }
2760
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002761 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2762 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2763 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2764 // explicitly qualified.
2765 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2766 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2767 }
2768
2769 // Check the use of this member.
2770 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2771 Owned(BaseExpr);
2772 return ExprError();
2773 }
2774
2775 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2776 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2777 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002778 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2779 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002780 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2781 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2782
2783 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2784 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2785 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2786 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2787 else {
2788 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2789 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2790 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2791
2792 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2793 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2794
2795 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2796 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2797 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2798 }
2799
2800 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002801 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002802 return ExprError();
2803 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002804 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805 }
2806
2807 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2808 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2809 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002810 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002811 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2812 }
2813
2814 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2815 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2816 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002817 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 MemberFn->getType()));
2819 }
2820
2821 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2822 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2823 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002824 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825 }
2826
2827 Owned(BaseExpr);
2828
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002829 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002831 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2832 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2833 else
2834 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2835 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002837 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2838 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002839 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002840 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841}
2842
2843/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2844/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2845/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2846/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2847/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2848/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2849/// an ordinary member expression.
2850///
2851/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2852/// fixed for ObjC++.
2853Sema::OwningExprResult
2854Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002855 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002856 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002858 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002859
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002860 // Perform default conversions.
2861 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002862
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002863 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002864 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2865
2866 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2867 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002868
2869 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002870 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002871 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2872 // call, and continue on.
2873 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2874 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2875 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2876 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2877 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002878 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2879 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002880 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2881 ->isRecordType()))) {
2882 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2883 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2884 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002885 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002886
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002887 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002888 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002889 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2890 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002891 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002892
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002893 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2894 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2895 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2896 }
2897 }
2898 }
2899
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002900 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2901 // use that.
2902 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002903 if (IsArrow) {
2904 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2905 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2906 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002907 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002908 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002909 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2910 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002911 }
2912 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002913 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2914 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2915 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2916 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002917 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002918 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002919 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002920
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002921 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2922 // use that.
2923 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2924 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2925 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2926 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2927 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2928 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2929 }
2930 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002931
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002932 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002933
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002934 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002935 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002936 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2937 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2938 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2939 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2940 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2941 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2942 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2943 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2944 // Check the use of this method.
2945 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2946 return ExprError();
2947 }
2948 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2949 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2950 Selector SetterSel =
2951 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2952 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2953 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2954 if (!Setter) {
2955 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2956 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002957 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002958 }
2959 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2960 if (!Setter)
2961 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002962
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002963 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2964 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002965
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002966 if (Getter || Setter) {
2967 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002968
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002969 if (Getter)
2970 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2971 else
2972 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2973 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2974 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002975 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002976 PType,
2977 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2978 }
2979 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2980 << MemberName << BaseType);
2981 }
2982 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002983
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002984 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
2985 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
2986 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002987 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002988 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002989
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002990 if (IsArrow) {
2991 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002992 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002993 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
2994 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002995 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
2996 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
2997 // struct MyRecord foo;
2998 // foo->bar
2999 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3000 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3001 // by now.
3002 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3003 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003004 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003005 IsArrow = false;
3006 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003007 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3008 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3009 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003010 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003011 } else {
3012 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3013 // type *foo;
3014 // foo.bar
3015 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3016 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3017 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3018 // the appropriate pointer type
3019 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3020 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3021 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3022 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3023 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003024 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003025 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3026 IsArrow = true;
3027 }
3028 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003029 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003030
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003031 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003032 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003033 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3034 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003035 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003036 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003037 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003038
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003039 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3040 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003041 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003042 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003043 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003044 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3045 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3046 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3047 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003048 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3049
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003050 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003051 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003052
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003053 if (!IV) {
3054 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3055 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3056 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003057 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003058 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003059 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003060 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3061 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003062 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3063 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003064 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003065 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003066 }
3067 }
3068
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003069 if (IV) {
3070 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3071 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3072 // error cases.
3073 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3074 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003075
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003076 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3077 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3078 return ExprError();
3079 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3080 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3081 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3082 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3083 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3084 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3085 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3086 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3087 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3088 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3089 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3090 // AST for a function decl.
3091 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003092 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003093 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3094 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3095 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3096 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3097 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3098 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003099
3100 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3101 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003102 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003103 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003104 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003105 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3106 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003107 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003108 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003109 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003110
3111 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3112 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003113 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003114 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003115 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003116 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003117 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003118 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003119 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003120 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003121 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3122 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003123 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003124 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003125
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003126 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003127 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003128 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3129 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3130 // Check the use of this declaration
3131 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3132 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003133
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003134 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3135 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3136 }
3137 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3138 // Check the use of this method.
3139 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3140 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003141
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003142 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003143 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3144 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3145 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003146 }
3147 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003148
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003149 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003150 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003151 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003152
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003153 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3154 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003155 if (!IsArrow)
3156 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3157 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003158 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003159
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003160 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003161 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003162 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3163 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003164 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003165 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003166 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003167
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003168 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003169 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003170 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003171 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3172 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003173 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003174 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003175 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003176 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003177
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003178 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3179 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3180
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003181 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003182}
3183
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003184/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3185/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3186/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3187/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3188/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3189///
3190/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3191/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3192/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3193/// only be called
3194/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3195/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3196/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3197Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3198 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3199 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003200 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003201 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3202 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3203 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3204 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3205 return ExprError();
3206
3207 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3208
3209 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3210 DeclarationName Name;
3211 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3212 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3213 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3214 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3215
3216 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3217
3218 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3219 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3220 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3221
3222 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3223 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3224
3225 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3226 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003227 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3228 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003229 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003230 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3231 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3232 Name, NameLoc,
3233 TemplateArgs);
3234 } else {
3235 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3236 if (TemplateArgs) {
3237 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3238 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003239
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003240 // Re-derive the naming class.
3241 if (SS.isSet()) {
3242 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3243 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3244 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3245 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3246 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3247 } else {
3248 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3249 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3250 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3251 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3252 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3253 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003254 } else {
3255 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003256 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003257
3258 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3259 Owned(Base);
3260 return ExprError();
3261 }
3262
3263 if (Result.get()) {
3264 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3265 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3266 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3267 // call now.
3268 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3269 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003270 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003271
3272 return move(Result);
3273 }
3274 }
3275
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003276 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003277 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3278 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003279 }
3280
3281 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003282}
3283
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003284Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3285 FunctionDecl *FD,
3286 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3287 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3288 Diag (CallLoc,
3289 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3290 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003291 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003292 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3293 } else {
3294 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3295 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3296
3297 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003298 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3299 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003300
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003301 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3302 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003303 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003304
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003305 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003306 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003307 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003308
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003309 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3310 InitializedEntity Entity
3311 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3312 InitializationKind Kind
3313 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3314 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3315 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3316
3317 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003318 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003319 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3320 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003321 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003322
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003323 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003324 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003325 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003326 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003327
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003328 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3329 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3330 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003331 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3332 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003333 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3334 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003335 }
3336
3337 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003338 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003339}
3340
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003341/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3342/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3343/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3344/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3345/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3346/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003347bool
3348Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003349 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003350 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003351 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3352 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003353 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003354 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3355 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003356 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003357
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003358 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3359 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3360 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3361 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3362 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003363 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003364 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003365 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003366 }
3367
3368 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3369 // them.
3370 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3371 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3372 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3373 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003374 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003375 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003376 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3377 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3378 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003379 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003380 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003381 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003382 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003383 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003384 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003385 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3386 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3387 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3388 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3389 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003390 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003391 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003392 if (Invalid)
3393 return true;
3394 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3395 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3396 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003397
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003398 return false;
3399}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003400
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003401bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3402 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3403 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3404 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3405 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3406 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003407 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003408 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3409 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3410 bool Invalid = false;
3411 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3412 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3413 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3414 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003415 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003416 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003417 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003418
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003419 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003420 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3421 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003422
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003423 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3424 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003425 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003426 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003427 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003428
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003429 // Pass the argument
3430 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3431 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3432 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003433
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003434
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003435 InitializedEntity Entity =
3436 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3437 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3438 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3439 SourceLocation(),
3440 Owned(Arg));
3441 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3442 return true;
3443
3444 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003445 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003446 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003447
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003448 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003449 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003450 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3451 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003452
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003453 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003454 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003455 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003456 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003457
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003458 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003459 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003460 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003461 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003462 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003463 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003464 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003465 }
3466 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003467 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003468}
3469
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003470/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003471/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3472/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003473Action::OwningExprResult
3474Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3475 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003476 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003477 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003478
3479 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3480 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003481
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003482 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003483 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003484 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003485
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003486 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003487 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3488 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3489 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3490 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3491 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003492 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003493 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3494 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003495
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003496 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3497 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003498
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003499 NumArgs = 0;
3500 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003501
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003502 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3503 RParenLoc));
3504 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003505
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003506 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003507 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003508 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3509 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003510 bool Dependent = false;
3511 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3512 Dependent = true;
3513 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3514 Dependent = true;
3515
3516 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003517 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003518 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3519
3520 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3521 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3522 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3523 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3524
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003525 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3526
3527 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3528 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3529 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3530 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3531 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3532 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3533 // method template.
3534 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003535 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3536 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003537 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003538
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003539 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3540 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003541 }
3542
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003543 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003544 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003545 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003546 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003547 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3548 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003549 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003550
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003551 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003552 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003553 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3554 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003555 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3556 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003557 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003558
3559 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3560 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003561 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3562 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003563
3564 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3565 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003566 TheCall.get(), 0))
3567 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003568
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003569 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003570 RParenLoc))
3571 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003572
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003573 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3574 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003575 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003576 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3577 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003578 }
3579 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003580 }
3581
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003582 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003583 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003584 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003585
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003586 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003587 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3588 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003589 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003590 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003591 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003592
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003593 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3594 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3595 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3596
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003597 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3598}
3599
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003600/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3601/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003602/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3603/// block-pointer type.
3604///
3605/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3606Sema::OwningExprResult
3607Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3608 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3609 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3610 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3611 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3612
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003613 // Promote the function operand.
3614 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3615
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003616 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3617 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003618 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3619 Args, NumArgs,
3620 Context.BoolTy,
3621 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003622
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003623 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3624 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3625 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3626 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003627 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003628 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003629 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3630 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003631 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003632 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003633 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003634 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003635 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003636 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003637 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3638 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3639
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003640 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003641 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003642 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3643 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003644 return ExprError();
3645
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003646 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003647 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003648
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003649 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003650 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003651 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003652 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003653 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003654 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003655
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003656 if (FDecl) {
3657 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3658 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3659 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003660 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003661 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003662 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003663 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3664 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3665 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3666 }
3667 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003668 }
3669
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003670 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003671 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3672 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3673 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003674 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3675 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003676 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3677 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003678 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003679 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003680 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003681 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003682
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003683 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3684 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003685 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3686 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003687
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003688 // Check for sentinels
3689 if (NDecl)
3690 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003691
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003692 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003693 if (FDecl) {
3694 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3695 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003696
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003697 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003698 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3699 } else if (NDecl) {
3700 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3701 return ExprError();
3702 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003703
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003704 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003705}
3706
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003707Action::OwningExprResult
3708Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3709 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003710 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003711 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003712 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003713
3714 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3715 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3716 if (!TInfo)
3717 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3718
3719 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3720}
3721
3722Action::OwningExprResult
3723Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3724 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3725 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003726 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003727
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003728 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003729 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003730 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3731 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003732 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3733 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003734 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003735 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003736 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003737 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003738
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003739 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003740 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003741 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003742 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003743 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003744 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3745 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3746 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3747 &literalType);
3748 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003749 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003750 InitExpr.release();
3751 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003752
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003753 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003754 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003755 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003756 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003757 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003758
3759 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003760
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003761 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003762 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003763}
3764
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003765Action::OwningExprResult
3766Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003767 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3768 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3769 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003770
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003771 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003772 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003773
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003774 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3775 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003776 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003777 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003778}
3779
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003780static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3781 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003782 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003783 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3784
3785 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3786 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003787 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3788 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003789 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003790 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3791 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3792 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003793
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003794 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3795 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3796 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3797 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3798 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3799 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3800 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3801 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003802
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003803 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3804 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3805 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3806 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3807 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3808 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003809
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003810 // FIXME: Assert here.
3811 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3812 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3813}
3814
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003815/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003816bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003817 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003818 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003819 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003820 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003821 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3822 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003823
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003824 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003825
3826 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3827 // type needs to be scalar.
3828 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3829 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003830 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3831 return false;
3832 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003833
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003834 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003835 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003836 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3837 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003838 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003839 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3840 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003841 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003842 return false;
3843 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003844
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003845 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003846 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003847 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003848 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003849 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003850 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003851 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003852 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003853 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3854 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3855 break;
3856 }
3857 }
3858 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3859 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3860 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003861 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003862 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003863 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003864
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003865 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3866 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3867 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3868 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003869
3870 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003871 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003872 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3873 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003874 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003875 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003876
3877 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003878 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003879
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003880 if (castType->isVectorType())
3881 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3882 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3883 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3884
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003885 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3886 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003887
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003888 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003889 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3890 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3891 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3892 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3893 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3894 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3895 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3896 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3897 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3898 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003899 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003900
3901 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003902 return false;
3903}
3904
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003905bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3906 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003907 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003908
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003909 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003910 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003911 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003912 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003913 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003914 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003915 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003916 } else
3917 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003918 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003919 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003920
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003921 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003922 return false;
3923}
3924
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003925bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003926 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003927 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003928
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003929 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003930
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003931 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3932 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003933 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3934 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3935 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3936 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003937 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003938 return false;
3939 }
3940
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003941 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003942 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3943 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003944 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3945 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3946 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3947 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003948
3949 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3950 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3951 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003952
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003953 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003954 return false;
3955}
3956
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003957Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003958Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003959 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3960 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3961 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003962
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003963 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3964 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3965 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003966 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003967
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003968 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003969 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003970 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003971 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3972 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003973
3974 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3975}
3976
3977Action::OwningExprResult
3978Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3979 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3980 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3981
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003982 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003983 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003984 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003985 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003986 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00003987
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00003988 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003989 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003990 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00003991 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003992}
3993
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003994/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
3995/// of comma binary operators.
3996Action::OwningExprResult
3997Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
3998 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
3999 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4000 if (!E)
4001 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004002
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004003 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004004
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004005 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4006 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4007 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004008
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004009 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4010}
4011
4012Action::OwningExprResult
4013Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4014 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004015 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004016 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004017 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004018
4019 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004020 // then handle it as such.
4021 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4022 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4023 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4024 return ExprError();
4025 }
4026
4027 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4028 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4029 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4030
4031 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4032 // braces instead of the original commas.
4033 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004034 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4035 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004036 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4037 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004038 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004039 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004040 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004041 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4042 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004043 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004044 }
4045}
4046
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004047Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004048 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004049 MultiExprArg Val,
4050 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004051 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4052 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004053 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4054 Expr *expr;
4055 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4056 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4057 else
4058 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004059 return Owned(expr);
4060}
4061
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004062/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4063/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004064/// C99 6.5.15
4065QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4066 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004067 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4068 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4069 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4070
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004071 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4072 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4073 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4074 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4075 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4076 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004077
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004078 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004079 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4080 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4081 << CondTy;
4082 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004083 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004084
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004085 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004086 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4087 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004088
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004089 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4090 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004091 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4092 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4093 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004094 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004095
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004096 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4097 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004098 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4099 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004100 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004101 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004102 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004103 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004104 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004105 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004106
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004107 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004108 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004109 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4110 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4111 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4112 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4113 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4114 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4115 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004116 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4117 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004118 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004119 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004120 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4121 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004122 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004123 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004124 // promote the null to a pointer.
4125 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004126 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004127 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004128 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004129 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004130 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004131 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004132 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004133
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004134 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4135 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4136 QuestionLoc);
4137 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4138 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004139
4140
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004141 // Handle block pointer types.
4142 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4143 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4144 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4145 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004146 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4147 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004148 return destType;
4149 }
4150 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004151 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004152 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004153 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004154 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4155 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4156 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004157 return LHSTy;
4158 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004159 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004160 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4161 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004162
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004163 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4164 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004165 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004166 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004167 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4168 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4169 // to get a consistent AST.
4170 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004171 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4172 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004173 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004174 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004175 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004176 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4177 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004178 return LHSTy;
4179 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004180
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004181 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4182 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4183 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004184 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4185 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004186
4187 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4188 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4189 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004190 QualType destPointee
4191 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004192 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004193 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4194 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4195 // Promote to void*.
4196 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004197 return destType;
4198 }
4199 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004200 QualType destPointee
4201 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004202 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004203 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004204 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004205 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004206 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004207 return destType;
4208 }
4209
4210 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4211 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4212 return LHSTy;
4213 }
4214 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4215 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4216 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4217 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4218 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4219 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4220 // to get a consistent AST.
4221 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004222 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4223 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004224 return incompatTy;
4225 }
4226 // The pointer types are compatible.
4227 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4228 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4229 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4230 // type.
4231 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4232 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004233 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4234 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004235 return LHSTy;
4236 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004237
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004238 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4239 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4240 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4241 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004242 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004243 return RHSTy;
4244 }
4245 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4246 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4247 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004248 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004249 return LHSTy;
4250 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004251
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004252 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004253 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4254 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004255 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004256}
4257
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004258/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4259/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4260QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4261 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4262 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4263 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004264
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004265 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4266 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4267 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4268 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4269 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4270 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4271 return LHSTy;
4272 }
4273 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4274 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4275 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4276 return RHSTy;
4277 }
4278 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4279 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4280 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4281 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4282 return LHSTy;
4283 }
4284 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4285 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4286 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4287 return RHSTy;
4288 }
4289 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4290 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4291 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4292 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4293 return LHSTy;
4294 }
4295 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4296 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4297 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4298 return RHSTy;
4299 }
4300 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4301 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004302
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004303 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4304 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4305 return LHSTy;
4306 }
4307 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4308 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4309 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004310
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004311 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4312 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4313 // type. This allows
4314 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4315 // where B is a subclass of A.
4316 //
4317 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4318 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4319 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4320 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004321
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004322 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4323 // It could return the composite type.
4324 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4325 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4326 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4327 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4328 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4329 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4330 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4331 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4332 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4333 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4334 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4335 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4336 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4337 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004338 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004339 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4340 ;
4341 else {
4342 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4343 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4344 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4345 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4346 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4347 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4348 return incompatTy;
4349 }
4350 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4351 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4352 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4353 return compositeType;
4354 }
4355 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4356 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4357 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4358 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4359 QualType destPointee
4360 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4361 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4362 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4363 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4364 // Promote to void*.
4365 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4366 return destType;
4367 }
4368 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4369 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4370 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4371 QualType destPointee
4372 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4373 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4374 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4375 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4376 // Promote to void*.
4377 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return destType;
4379 }
4380 return QualType();
4381}
4382
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004383/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004384/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004385Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4386 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4387 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4388 ExprArg RHS) {
4389 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4390 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004391
4392 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4393 // was the condition.
4394 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4395 if (isLHSNull)
4396 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004397
4398 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004399 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004400 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004401 return ExprError();
4402
4403 Cond.release();
4404 LHS.release();
4405 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004406 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004407 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004408 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004409}
4410
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004411// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004412// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004413// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4414// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4415// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004416Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004417Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004418 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004419
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004420 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4421 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4422 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4423 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4424 return Compatible;
4425 }
4426
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004427 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004428 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4429 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004430
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004431 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004432 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4433 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004434
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004435 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004436
4437 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4438 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4439 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004440 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004441 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004442 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004443
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004444 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4445 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004446 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004447 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004448 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004449 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004450
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004451 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004452 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4453 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004454 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004455
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004456 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004457 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004458 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004459
4460 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004461 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4462 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004463 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004464 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004465 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004466 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4467 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4468 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4469 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4470 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4471 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004472 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004473 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004474 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004475 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004476
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004477 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004478 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004479 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004480 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004481
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004482 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4483 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4484 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4485 // warning can be disabled.
4486 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4487 return ConvTy;
4488 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4489 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004490
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004491 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4492 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4493 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4494 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4495 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4496 do {
4497 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4498 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004499
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004500 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4501 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4502 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004503
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004504 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004505 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004506 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004507
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004508 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004509 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004510 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004511 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004512}
4513
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004514/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4515/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4516/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4517// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004518Sema::AssignConvertType
4519Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004520 QualType rhsType) {
4521 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004522
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004523 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004524 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4525 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004526
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004527 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4528 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4529 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004530
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004531 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004533 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004534 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004535 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004536
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004537 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4538 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4539 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4540 }
4541 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004543 return ConvTy;
4544}
4545
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004546/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4547/// for assignment compatibility.
4548Sema::AssignConvertType
4549Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004550 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4551 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004552 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4553 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004554 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004555 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004556 }
4557 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4558 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004559 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4560 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004561 return IncompatiblePointer;
4562 return Compatible;
4563 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004564 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004565 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004566 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004567 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4568 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4569 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4570 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4571 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4572 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004573
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004574 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4575 return Compatible;
4576 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4577 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004578 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004579}
4580
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004581/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4582/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004583/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4584///
4585/// int a, *pint;
4586/// short *pshort;
4587/// struct foo *pfoo;
4588///
4589/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4590/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4591/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4592/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4593///
4594/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004595/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004596///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004597Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004598Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004599 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4600 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004601 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4602 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004603
4604 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004605 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004606
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004607 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4608 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4609 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4610 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4611 return Compatible;
4612 }
4613
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004614 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4615 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4616 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4617 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4618 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4619 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4620 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004621 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004622 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004623 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004624 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004625 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004626 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4627 // to the same ExtVector type.
4628 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4629 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4630 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4631 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4632 return Compatible;
4633 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004634
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004635 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004636 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004637 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004638 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004639 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4640 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004641 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004642 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004643 }
4644 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004645 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004646
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004647 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004648 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004649
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004650 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004651 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004652 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004653
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004654 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004655 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004656
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004657 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004658 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004659 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4660 return Compatible;
4661 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004662 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004663 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4664 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004665 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004666
4667 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004668 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004669 return Compatible;
4670 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004671 return Incompatible;
4672 }
4673
4674 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4675 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004676 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004677
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004678 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004679 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004680 return Compatible;
4681
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004682 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4683 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004684
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004685 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004686 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004687 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004688 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004689 return Incompatible;
4690 }
4691
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004692 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4693 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4694 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004695
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004696 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004697 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004698 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4699 return Compatible;
4700 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004701 }
4702 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004703 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004704 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004705 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004706 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4707 return Compatible;
4708 }
4709 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4710 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4711 return Compatible;
4712 return Incompatible;
4713 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004714 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004715 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004716 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4717 return Compatible;
4718
4719 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004720 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004721
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004722 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004723 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004724
4725 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004726 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004727 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004728 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004729 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004730 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4731 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4732 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4733 return Compatible;
4734
4735 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4736 return PointerToInt;
4737
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004738 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004739 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004740 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4741 return Compatible;
4742 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004743 }
4744 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004745 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004746 return Compatible;
4747 return Incompatible;
4748 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004749
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004750 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004751 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004752 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004753 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004754 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004755}
4756
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004757/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4758/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004759static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004760 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4761 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4762 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004763 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004764 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004765 SourceLocation());
4766 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4767 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4768
4769 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4770 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004771 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004772 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004773 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004774}
4775
4776Sema::AssignConvertType
4777Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4778 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4779
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004780 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004781 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4782 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004783 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004784 return Incompatible;
4785
4786 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4787 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4788 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4789 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004790 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4791 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004792 it != itend; ++it) {
4793 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4794 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4795 // 1) void pointer
4796 // 2) null pointer constant
4797 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004798 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004799 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004800 InitField = *it;
4801 break;
4802 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004803
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004804 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004805 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004806 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004807 InitField = *it;
4808 break;
4809 }
4810 }
4811
4812 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4813 == Compatible) {
4814 InitField = *it;
4815 break;
4816 }
4817 }
4818
4819 if (!InitField)
4820 return Incompatible;
4821
4822 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4823 return Compatible;
4824}
4825
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004826Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004827Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004828 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4829 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4830 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4831 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4832 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004833 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004834 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004835 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004836 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004837 }
4838
4839 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4840 // structures.
4841 }
4842
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004843 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4844 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004845 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4846 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004847 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004848 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004849 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004850 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004851 return Compatible;
4852 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004853
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004854 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004855 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004856 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004857 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004858 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004859 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004860 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004861 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004862
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004863 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4864 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004865
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004866 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4867 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004868 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4869 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4870 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4871 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004872 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004873 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4874 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004875 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004876}
4877
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004878QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004879 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004880 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004881 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004882 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004883}
4884
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004885QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004886 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004887 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004888 QualType lhsType =
4889 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4890 QualType rhsType =
4891 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004892
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004893 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004894 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004895 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004896
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004897 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4898 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004899 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4900 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004901 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4902 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004903 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004904 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004905 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4906 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4907 return lhsType;
4908 }
4909
4910 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4911 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004912 }
4913 }
4914 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004915
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004916 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4917 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4918 bool swapped = false;
4919 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4920 swapped = true;
4921 std::swap(rex, lex);
4922 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4923 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004924
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004925 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004926 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004927 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4928 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4929 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004930 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004931 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4932 return lhsType;
4933 }
4934 }
4935 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4936 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4937 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004938 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004939 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4940 return lhsType;
4941 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004942 }
4943 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004944
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004945 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004946 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004947 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004948 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004949 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004950}
4951
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004952QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4953 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004954 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004955 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004956
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004957 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004958
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004959 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4960 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4961 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004962
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004963 // Check for division by zero.
4964 if (isDiv &&
4965 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004966 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004967 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004968
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004969 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004970}
4971
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004972QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004973 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004974 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4975 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4976 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4977 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4978 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004979
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004980 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004981
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004982 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4983 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004984
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004985 // Check for remainder by zero.
4986 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004987 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
4988 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004989
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004990 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00004991}
4992
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004993QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004994 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00004995 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4996 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4997 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
4998 return compType;
4999 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005000
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005001 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005002
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005003 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005004 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5005 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5006 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005007 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005008 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005009
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005010 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5011 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005012 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005013 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5014
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005015 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005016
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005017 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005018 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005019
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005020 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5021 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005022 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5023 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005024 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005025 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005026 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005027
5028 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5029 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5030 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005031 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005032 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5033 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5034 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5035 return QualType();
5036 }
5037
5038 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5039 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5040 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005041 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005042 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005043 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005044 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005045 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5046 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005047 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5048 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005049 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005050 return QualType();
5051 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005052 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005053 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005054 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5055 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5056 return QualType();
5057 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005058
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005059 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005060 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5061 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5062 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5063 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5064 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005065 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005066 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5067 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005068 return PExp->getType();
5069 }
5070 }
5071
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005072 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005073}
5074
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005075// C99 6.5.6
5076QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005077 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5078 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5079 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5080 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5081 return compType;
5082 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005083
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005084 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005085
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005086 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005087
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005088 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005089 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5090 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005092 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005093 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005094
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005095 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005096 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005097 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005098
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005099 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005100
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005101 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5102 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5103 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5104 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5105 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5106 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5107 return QualType();
5108 }
5109
5110 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5111 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5112 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5113 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5114 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005115 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005116 return QualType();
5117 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005118
5119 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5120 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5121 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005122 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005123 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005124 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005125 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005126 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005127
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005128 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005129 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005130 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5131 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5132 return QualType();
5133 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005134
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005135 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005136 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5137 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5138 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5139 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5140 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5141 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005142 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005143 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5144
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005145 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005146 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005147 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005148
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005149 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005150 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005151 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005152
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005153 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5154 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5155 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5156 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5157 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5158 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5159 return QualType();
5160 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005161
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005162 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5163 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5164 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5165 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005166 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005167 return QualType();
5168 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005169
5170 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5171 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5172 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5173 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5174 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005175 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5176 << rex->getSourceRange()
5177 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005178 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005179
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005180 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5181 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5182 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5183 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5184 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5185 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5186 return QualType();
5187 }
5188 } else {
5189 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5190 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5191 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5192 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5193 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5194 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5195 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5196 return QualType();
5197 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005198 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005199
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005200 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5201 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5202 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5203 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5204 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005205 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005206 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005207
5208 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005209 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5210 }
5211 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005212
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005213 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005214}
5215
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005216// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005217QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005218 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005219 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5220 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005221 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005222
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005223 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5224 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5225 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5226
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005227 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5228 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005229 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5230 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5231 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5232 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5233 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005234 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005235 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005236 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005237
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005238 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005239
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005240 // Sanity-check shift operands
5241 llvm::APSInt Right;
5242 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005243 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5244 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005245 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005246 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5247 else {
5248 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5249 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5250 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5251 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5252 }
5253 }
5254
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005255 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005256 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005257}
5258
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005259// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005260QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005261 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5262 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5263
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005264 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005265 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005266 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005267
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005268 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005269 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5270 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5271 else {
5272 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5273 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5274 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005275 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5276 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005277
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005278 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5279 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005280 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5281 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5282 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005283 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005284 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005285 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5286 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5287 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5288 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005289 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5290 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005291 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005292
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005293 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5294 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5295 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5296 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005297
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005298 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5299 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005300 Expr *literalString = 0;
5301 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005302 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005303 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005304 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005305 literalString = lex;
5306 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005307 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5308 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005309 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005310 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005311 literalString = rex;
5312 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5313 }
5314
5315 if (literalString) {
5316 std::string resultComparison;
5317 switch (Opc) {
5318 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5319 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5320 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5321 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5322 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5323 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5324 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5325 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005326
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005327 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5328 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5329 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005330 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005331 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005332 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005333
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005334 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005335 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005336
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005337 if (isRelational) {
5338 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005339 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005340 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005341 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005342 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005343 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005344
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005345 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005346 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005347 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005348
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005349 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005350 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005351 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005352 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005353
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005354 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5355 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5356 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005357 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005358 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005359 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005360 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005361 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005362
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005363 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005364 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5365 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005366 if (!isRelational &&
5367 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5368 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5369 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5370 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5371 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5372 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5373 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5374 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5375 return ResultTy;
5376 }
5377 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005378 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5379 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5380 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5381 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5382 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5383 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005384 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005385 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005386 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005387 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005388 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005389 if (T.isNull()) {
5390 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5391 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5392 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005393 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005394 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005395 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005396 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005397 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005398 }
5399
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005400 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5401 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005402 return ResultTy;
5403 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005404 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5405 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5406 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5407 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5408 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5409 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5410 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5411 }
5412 } else if (!isRelational &&
5413 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5414 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5415 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5416 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5417 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5418 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5419 }
5420 } else {
5421 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005422 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005423 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005424 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005425 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005426 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005427 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005428 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005429
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005430 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005431 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005432 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005433 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005434 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5435 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005436 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005437 return ResultTy;
5438 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005439 if (LHSIsNull &&
5440 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5441 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005442 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005443 return ResultTy;
5444 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005445
5446 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005447 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005448 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5449 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005450 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5451 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5452 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5453 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5454 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5455 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5456 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5457 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005458 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005459 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005460 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005461 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005462 if (T.isNull()) {
5463 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005464 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005465 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005466 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005467 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005468 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005469 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005470 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005472
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005473 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5474 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005475 return ResultTy;
5476 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005477
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005478 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005479 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5480 return ResultTy;
5481 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005482
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005483 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005484 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005485 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5486 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005487
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005488 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005489 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005490 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005491 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005492 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005493 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005494 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005495 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005496 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005497 if (!isRelational
5498 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5499 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005500 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005501 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005502 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005503 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005504 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5505 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5506 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005507 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005508 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005509 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005510 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005511
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005512 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005513 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005514 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5515 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005516 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005517 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005518 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005519 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005520
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005521 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5522 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005523 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005524 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005525 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005526 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005527 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005528 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005529 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005530 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005531 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5532 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005533 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005534 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005535 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005536 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005537 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005538 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5539 if (RHSIsNull) {
5540 if (isRelational)
5541 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5542 } else if (isRelational)
5543 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5544 else
5545 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005546
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005547 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005548 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005549 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005550 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005551 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005552 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005553 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005554 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005555 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5556 if (LHSIsNull) {
5557 if (isRelational)
5558 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5559 } else if (isRelational)
5560 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5561 else
5562 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005563
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005564 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005565 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005566 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005567 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005568 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005569 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005570 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005571 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005572 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5573 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005574 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005575 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005576 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005577 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5578 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005579 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005580 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005581 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005582 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005583}
5584
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005585/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005586/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005587/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5588/// types.
5589QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005590 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005591 bool isRelational) {
5592 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5593 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005594 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005595 if (vType.isNull())
5596 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005597
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005598 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5599 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005600
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005601 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5602 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5603 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5604 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5605 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5606 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5607 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005608 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005609 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005610
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005611 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5612 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5613 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005614 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005615 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005616
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005617 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5618 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5619 // elements for floating point vectors.
5620 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5621 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005622
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005623 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005624 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005625 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005626 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005627 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005628 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5629
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005630 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005631 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005632 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5633}
5634
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005635inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005636 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005637 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005638 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005639
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005640 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005641
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005642 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005643 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005644 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005645}
5646
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005647inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005648 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005649 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5650 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5651 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005652
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005653 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5654 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005655
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005656 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005657 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005658
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005659 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5660 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5661 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5662 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5663 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5664 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5665 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005666
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005667 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005668 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005669 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005670
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005671 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5672 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5673 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5674 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005675
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005676 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005677 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005678 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005679
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005680 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5681 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5682 // The result is a bool.
5683 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005684}
5685
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005686/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5687/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5688/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5689///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005690static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005691 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5692 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5693 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5694 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005695 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005696 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5697 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5698 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5699 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005700 }
5701 }
5702 return false;
5703}
5704
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005705/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5706/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5707static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005708 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005709 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005710 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005711 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5712 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005713 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5714 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005715
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005716 unsigned Diag = 0;
5717 bool NeedType = false;
5718 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005719 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005720 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005721 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5722 NeedType = true;
5723 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005724 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005725 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5726 NeedType = true;
5727 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005728 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005729 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5730 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005731 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5732 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005733 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005734 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5735 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005736 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5737 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005738 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5739 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005740 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005741 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005742 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005743 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005744 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5745 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005746 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005747 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5748 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005749 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5750 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5751 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005752 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5753 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5754 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005755 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5756 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5757 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005758 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005759
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005760 SourceRange Assign;
5761 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5762 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005763 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005764 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005765 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005766 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005767 return true;
5768}
5769
5770
5771
5772// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005773QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5774 SourceLocation Loc,
5775 QualType CompoundType) {
5776 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5777 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005778 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005779
5780 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5781 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005782
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005783 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005784 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005785 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005786 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005787 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5788 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5789 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005790 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005791 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005792 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005793 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005794
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005795 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5796 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5797 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005798 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005799 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5800 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5801 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5802 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5803 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005804 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005805 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005806 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5807 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5808 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005809 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5810 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005811 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5812 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5813 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005814 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005815 }
5816 } else {
5817 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005818 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005819 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005820
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005821 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005822 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005823 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005824
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005825 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5826 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005827 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005828 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5829 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005830 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005831 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005832 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005833}
5834
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005835// C99 6.5.17
5836QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005837 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005838 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5839 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5840 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005841
5842 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5843 // incomplete in C++).
5844
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005845 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005846}
5847
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005848/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5849/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005850QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005851 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005852 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5853 return Context.DependentTy;
5854
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005855 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5856 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005857
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005858 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5859 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5860 if (!isInc) {
5861 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5862 return QualType();
5863 }
5864 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5865 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5866 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005867 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005868 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5869 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005871 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005872 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005873 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5874 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5875 << Op->getSourceRange();
5876 return QualType();
5877 }
5878
5879 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005880 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005881 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005882 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5883 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5884 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5885 return QualType();
5886 }
5887
5888 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005889 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005890 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005891 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005892 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005893 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005894 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005895 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005896 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005897 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5898 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5899 return QualType();
5900 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005901 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005902 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5903 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005904 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005905 } else {
5906 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005907 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005908 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005909 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005910 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005911 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005912 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005913 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005914 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5915 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5916 // operand.
5917 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5918 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005919}
5920
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005921/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005922/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005923/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5924/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5925/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5926/// - &(x) => x
5927/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5928/// - &s.xx => s
5929/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5930/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5931/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5932/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005933static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005934 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005935 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005936 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005937 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005938 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5939 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5940 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005941 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005942 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005943 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005944 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005945 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005946 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5947 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005948 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5949 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5950 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5951 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5952 }
5953 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005954 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005955 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5956 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005957
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005958 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005959 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5960 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5961 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5962 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5963 default:
5964 return 0;
5965 }
5966 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005967 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005968 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005969 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005970 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5971 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005972 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005973 default:
5974 return 0;
5975 }
5976}
5977
5978/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005979/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005980/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005981/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00005982/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005983/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00005984/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005985QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005986 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
5987 op = op->IgnoreParens();
5988
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00005989 if (op->isTypeDependent())
5990 return Context.DependentTy;
5991
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00005992 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
5993 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
5994 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
5995 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
5996 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
5997 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
5998 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
5999 }
6000 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6001 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6002 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006003 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006004 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006005
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006006 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6007 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6008 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6009 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6010 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6011 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6012 // branch of the if, below.
6013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6014 << dcl;
6015 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6016
6017 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6018 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6019 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6020 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006021 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6022 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6023 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6024 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6025 if (isSFINAEContext())
6026 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006027 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006028 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006029 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006030 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006031 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006032 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6033 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006034 return QualType();
6035 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006036 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006037 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6038 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6039 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006040 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006041 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006042 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006043 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006044 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006045 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006046 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6047 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6048 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6049 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6050 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006051 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6052 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006053 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6054 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006055 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6056 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006057 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006058 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006059 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6060 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006061 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006062 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6063 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006064 return QualType();
6065 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006066 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006067 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006068 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006069 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006070 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6071 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006072 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006073 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006074 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6075 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006076 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006077 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6078 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6079 return QualType();
6080 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006081
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006082 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6083 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006084 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006085 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006086 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006087 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006088 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006089 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6090 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006091 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6092 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6093 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006094 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006095 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006096
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006097 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6098 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6099 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6100 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6101 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6102 }
6103
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006104 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006105 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006106}
6107
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006108QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006109 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6110 return Context.DependentTy;
6111
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006112 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6113 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006114
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006115 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6116 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6117 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6118 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006119 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006120 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006121
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006122 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006123 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006124
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006125 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006126 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006127 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006128}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006129
6130static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6131 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6132 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6133 switch (Kind) {
6134 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006135 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6136 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006137 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6138 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6139 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6140 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6141 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6142 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6143 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6144 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6145 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6146 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6147 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6148 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6149 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6150 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6151 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6152 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6153 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6154 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6155 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6156 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6157 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6158 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6159 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6160 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6161 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6162 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6163 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6164 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6165 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6166 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6167 }
6168 return Opc;
6169}
6170
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006171static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6172 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6173 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6174 switch (Kind) {
6175 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6176 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6177 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6178 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6179 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6180 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6181 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6182 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6183 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006184 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6185 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006186 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006187 }
6188 return Opc;
6189}
6190
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006191/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6192/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6193/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006194Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6195 unsigned Op,
6196 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006197 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006198 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006199 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6200 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6201 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006202
6203 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006204 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6205 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6206 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006207 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6208 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6209 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6210 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6211 break;
6212 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006213 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006214 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6215 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006216 break;
6217 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6218 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6219 break;
6220 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6221 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6222 break;
6223 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6224 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6225 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006226 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006227 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6228 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6229 break;
6230 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6231 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6232 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6233 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006234 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006235 break;
6236 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6237 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006238 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006239 break;
6240 case BinaryOperator::And:
6241 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6242 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6243 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6244 break;
6245 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6246 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6247 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6248 break;
6249 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6250 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006251 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6252 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006253 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6254 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6255 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006256 break;
6257 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006258 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6259 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6260 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6261 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006262 break;
6263 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006264 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6265 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6266 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006267 break;
6268 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006269 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6270 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6271 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006272 break;
6273 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6274 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006275 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6276 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6277 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6278 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006279 break;
6280 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6281 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6282 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006283 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6284 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6285 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6286 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006287 break;
6288 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6289 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6290 break;
6291 }
6292 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006293 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006294 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006295 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6296 else
6297 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006298 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6299 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006300}
6301
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006302/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6303/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006304static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6305 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006306 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6307 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6308 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006309 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006310 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6311
6312 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6313 return;
6314
6315 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6316 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6317 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006318 return;
6319 }
6320
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006321 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6322 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006323 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006324
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006325 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006326 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006327
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006328 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6329 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6330 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6331 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006332 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006333 return;
6334 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006335
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006336 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006337 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6338 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006339}
6340
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006341/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6342/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6343/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6344/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006345static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6346 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006347 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6348 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6349 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6350 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006351 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006352 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006353 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6354
6355 // Subs are not binary operators.
6356 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6357 return;
6358
6359 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6360 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006361 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6362 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006363 return;
6364
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006365 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006366 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006367 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006368 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6369 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006370 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006371 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006372 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6373 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6374 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6375 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006376 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006377 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006378 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006379 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6380 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006381 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006382 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006383 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6384 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6385 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6386 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006387}
6388
6389/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6390/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6391/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6392static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6393 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006394 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006395 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6396}
6397
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006398// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006399Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6400 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6401 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006402 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006403 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006404
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006405 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6406 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006407
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006408 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6409 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6410
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006411 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6412}
6413
6414Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6415 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6416 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006417 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006418 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006419 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6420 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6421 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6422 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6423 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006424 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006425 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006426 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6427 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6428 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006429
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006430 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6431 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006432 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006433 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006434
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006435 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006436 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006437}
6438
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006439Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006440 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006441 ExprArg InputArg) {
6442 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006443
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006444 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006445 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006446 QualType resultType;
6447 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006448 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6449 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6450 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006451
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006452 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6453 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006454 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6455 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006456 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006457 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006458 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6459 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6460 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006461 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006462 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006463 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006464 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006465 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006466 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006467 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006468 break;
6469 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6470 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006471 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6472 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006473 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6474 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006475 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6476 break;
6477 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6478 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6479 break;
6480 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6481 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6482 resultType->isPointerType())
6483 break;
6484
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006485 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6486 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006487 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006488 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6489 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006490 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6491 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006492 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6493 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6494 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006495 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006496 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006497 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006498 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6499 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006500 break;
6501 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006502 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006503 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006504 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006505 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6506 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006507 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006508 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6509 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006510 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006511 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6512 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006513 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006514 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006515 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006516 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006517 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006518 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006519 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006520 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006521 }
6522 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006523 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006524
6525 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006526 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006527}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006528
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006529Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6530 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6531 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006532 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006533 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6534 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006535 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6536 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6537 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6538 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006539 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006540 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006541 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6542 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6543 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006544
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006545 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6546 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006547
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006548 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6549}
6550
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006551// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6552Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6553 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6554 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6555}
6556
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006557/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006558Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6559 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6560 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006561 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006562 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006563
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006564 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6565 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006566 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006567 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006568
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006569 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006570 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6571 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006572}
6573
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006574Sema::OwningExprResult
6575Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6576 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6577 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006578 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6579 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6580
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006581 bool isFileScope
6582 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006583 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006584 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006585
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006586 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6587 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6588 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006589
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006590 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6591 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6592 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006593
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006594 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6595 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6596 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6597 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6598 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006599
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006600 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006601 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006602 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006603
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006604 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6605 // expressions are not lvalues.
6606
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006607 substmt.release();
6608 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006609}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006610
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006611Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6612 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006613 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6614 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006615 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6616 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006617 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006618 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006619
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006620 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6621 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6622 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006623 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006624 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6625 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6626
6627 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6628 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6629 if (!Dependent
6630 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6631 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6632 << TypeRange))
6633 return ExprError();
6634
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006635 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6636 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006637 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6638 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006639 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006640 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6641 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006642
6643 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6644 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6645 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6646 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6647 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6648 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6649 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6650 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6651 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6652 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6653 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6654 if(!AT)
6655 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6656 << CurrentType);
6657 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6658 } else
6659 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6660
6661 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6662 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6663 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6664 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6665 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6666 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6667 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6668 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6669
6670 // Record this array index.
6671 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6672 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6673 continue;
6674 }
6675
6676 // Offset of a field.
6677 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6678 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6679 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6680 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6681 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6682 continue;
6683 }
6684
6685 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6686 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6687 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6688 return ExprError();
6689
6690 // Look for the designated field.
6691 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6692 if (!RC)
6693 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6694 << CurrentType);
6695 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6696
6697 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6698 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6699 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6700 // (clause 9).
6701 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6702 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6703 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6704 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6705 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6706 << CurrentType))
6707 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6708 }
6709
6710 // Look for the field.
6711 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6712 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6713 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6714 if (!MemberDecl)
6715 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6716 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6717 OC.LocEnd));
6718
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006719 // C99 7.17p3:
6720 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6721 //
6722 // We diagnose this as an error.
6723 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6724 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6725 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6726 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6727 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6728 return ExprError();
6729 }
6730
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006731 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6732 // the base class indirections.
6733 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6734 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6735 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6736 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6737 Paths)) {
6738 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6739 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6740 B != BEnd; ++B)
6741 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6742 }
6743
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006744 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006745 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006746 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6747 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6748 unsigned n = Path.size();
6749 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6750 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6751 } else {
6752 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6753 }
6754 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6755 }
6756
6757 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6758 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6759 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6760}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006761
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006762Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6763 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6764 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6765 TypeTy *argty,
6766 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6767 unsigned NumComponents,
6768 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6769
6770 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6771 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6772 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6773 return ExprError();
6774
6775 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6776 if (!ArgTInfo)
6777 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6778
6779 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6780 RPLoc);
6781 }
6782
6783 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6784 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6785
6786 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6787
6788 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6789 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6790 // a struct/union/class.
6791 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6792 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6793
6794 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6795 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6796
6797 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6798 // the offsetof designators.
6799 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6800 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6801 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6802 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6803
6804 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6805 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6806 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6807 // a system header!
6808 if (NumComponents != 1)
6809 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6810 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6811
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006812 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006813 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006814
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006815 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6816 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6817 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006818
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006819 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6820 // leaks like a sieve.
6821 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6822 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6823 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6824 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6825 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6826 if (!AT) {
6827 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006828 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006829 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006830 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006831
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006832 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006833
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006834 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6835 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006836 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006837
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006838 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6839 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006840 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006841 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006842 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006843 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006844 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6845
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006846 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6847 OC.LocEnd);
6848 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006849 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006850
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006851 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006852 if (!RC) {
6853 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006854 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006855 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006856 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006857
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006858 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6859 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006860 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006861 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6862 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6863 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006864 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6865 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006866 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006867 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006868
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006869 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6870 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006871
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006872 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006873 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006874 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006875 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006876 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6877
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006878 // C99 7.17p3:
6879 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6880 //
6881 // We diagnose this as an error.
6882 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6883 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6884 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6885 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6886 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6887 return ExprError();
6888 }
6889
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006890 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6891 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006892 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006893 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006894 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006895 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006896 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6897 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006898 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6899 // doesn't matter here.
6900 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006901 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006902 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006903 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006904 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006905
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006906 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6907 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006908}
6909
6910
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006911Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6912 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6913 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006914 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6915 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6916 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006917
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006918 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006919
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006920 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6921 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6922 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6923 return ExprError();
6924 }
6925
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006926 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6927 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006928}
6929
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006930Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6931 ExprArg cond,
6932 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6933 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6934 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6935 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6936 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006937
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006938 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6939
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006940 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006941 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006942 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006943 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006944 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006945 } else {
6946 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6947 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6948 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6949 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006950 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6951 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6952 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006953
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006954 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6955 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006956 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6957 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006958 }
6959
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006960 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6961 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006962 resType, RPLoc,
6963 resType->isDependentType(),
6964 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006965}
6966
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006967//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6968// Clang Extensions.
6969//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6970
6971/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006972void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006973 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6974 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6975 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6976 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006977}
6978
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006979void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006980 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006981 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006982
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006983 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6984 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006985 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006986 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
6987
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00006988 if (T->isArrayType()) {
6989 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6990 diag::err_block_returns_array);
6991 return;
6992 }
6993
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006994 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
6995 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006996 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
6997 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006998
6999 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
7000 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007001 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007002 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007003 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007004 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007005 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7006 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007007 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007008
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007009 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007010 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007011 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7012 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7013 return;
7014 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007015
7016 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007017 return;
7018 }
7019
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007020 // Analyze arguments to block.
7021 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
7022 "Not a function declarator!");
7023 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007024
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007025 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
7026 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007027
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007028 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
7029 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
7030 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
7031 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00007032 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
7033 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007034 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007035 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007036 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007037 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
7038 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
7039 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7040 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7041 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7042 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7043 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
7044 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
7045 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007046 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007047 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00007048 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007049 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00007050 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007051 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007052
7053 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7054 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7055
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007056 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007057 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7058 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7059
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007060 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007061 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7062 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7063 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7064
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007065 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007066 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007067 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007068
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007069 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007070 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007071 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007072 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007073 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007074 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7075 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007076
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007077 // Analyze the return type.
7078 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007079 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007080
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007081 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007082 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007083 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7084 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7085 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007086 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007087}
7088
7089/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7090/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7091void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007092 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007093 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007094 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007095 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007096}
7097
7098/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7099/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007100Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7101 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007102 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7103 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7104 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007105
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007106 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007107
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007108 PopDeclContext();
7109
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007110 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007111 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7112 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007113
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007114 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7115 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7116 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007117
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007118 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007119 QualType BlockTy;
7120 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007121 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007122 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007123 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007124 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007125 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007126 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007127
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007128 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007129 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007130 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007131
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007132 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007133 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007134 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007135
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007136 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007137
7138 bool Good = true;
7139 // Check goto/label use.
7140 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7141 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7142 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7143
7144 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7145 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7146 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7147 continue;
7148
7149 // Emit error.
7150 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7151 Good = false;
7152 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007153 if (!Good) {
7154 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007155 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007156 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007157
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007158 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007159 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7160 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7161 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007162
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007163 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7164 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007165 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007166 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007167}
7168
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007169Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7170 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7171 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007172 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007173 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7174 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007175
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007176 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007177
7178 // Get the va_list type
7179 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007180 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7181 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7182 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7183 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007184 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007185 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7186 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7187 } else {
7188 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7189 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007190 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007191 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007192 return ExprError();
7193 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007194
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007195 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7196 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007197 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7198 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007199 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007200 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007201
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007202 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007203 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007204
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007205 expr.release();
7206 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7207 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007208}
7209
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007210Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007211 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7212 // pointers on the target.
7213 QualType Ty;
7214 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7215 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7216 else
7217 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7218
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007219 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007220}
7221
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007222static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007223 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007224 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7225 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007226
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007227 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7228 if (!PT)
7229 return;
7230
7231 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7232 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7233 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7234 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7235 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7236 return;
7237 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007238
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007239 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7240 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7241 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7242 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007243
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007244 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007245}
7246
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007247bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7248 SourceLocation Loc,
7249 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007250 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7251 bool *Complained) {
7252 if (Complained)
7253 *Complained = false;
7254
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007255 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7256 bool isInvalid = false;
7257 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007258 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007259
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007260 switch (ConvTy) {
7261 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7262 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007263 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007264 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7265 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007266 case IntToPointer:
7267 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7268 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007269 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007270 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007271 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7272 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007273 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7274 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7275 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007276 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7277 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7278 break;
7279 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007280 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7281 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7282 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7283 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7284 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7285 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7286 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7287 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7288 // C++ semantics.
7289 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7290 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7291 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007292 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7293 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007294 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007295 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007296 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007297 case IntToBlockPointer:
7298 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7299 break;
7300 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007301 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007302 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007303 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007304 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007305 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7306 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7307 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007308 case IncompatibleVectors:
7309 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7310 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007311 case Incompatible:
7312 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7313 isInvalid = true;
7314 break;
7315 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007316
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007317 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7318 switch (Action) {
7319 case AA_Assigning:
7320 case AA_Initializing:
7321 // The destination type comes first.
7322 FirstType = DstType;
7323 SecondType = SrcType;
7324 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007325
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007326 case AA_Returning:
7327 case AA_Passing:
7328 case AA_Converting:
7329 case AA_Sending:
7330 case AA_Casting:
7331 // The source type comes first.
7332 FirstType = SrcType;
7333 SecondType = DstType;
7334 break;
7335 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007336
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007337 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007338 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007339 if (Complained)
7340 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007341 return isInvalid;
7342}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007343
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007344bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007345 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7346 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7347 if (Result)
7348 *Result = ICEResult;
7349 return false;
7350 }
7351
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007352 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7353
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007354 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007355 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7356 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7357
7358 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7359 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7360 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7361 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7362 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7363 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7364 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007365
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007366 return true;
7367 }
7368
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007369 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7370 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007371
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007372 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7373 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7374 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007375
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007376 if (Result)
7377 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7378 return false;
7379}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007380
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007381void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007382Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007383 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7384 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007385}
7386
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007387void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007388Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7389 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7390 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7391 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007392
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007393 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7394 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7395 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7396 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7397 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007398 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007399 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7400 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7401 I != IEnd; ++I)
7402 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7403 }
7404
7405 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7406 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7407 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7408 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7409 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7410 I != IEnd; ++I)
7411 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7412 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007413 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007414
7415 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7416 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7417 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7418 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007419 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007420 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7421 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7422 ExprTemporaries.end());
7423
7424 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7425 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007426}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007427
7428/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7429///
7430/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7431/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7432/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7433/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7434///
7435/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7436///
7437/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7438void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7439 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007440
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007441 if (D->isUsed())
7442 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007443
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007444 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7445 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7446 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7447 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007448 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007449 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007450 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007451 return;
7452 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007453
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007454 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7455 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007456
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007457 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7458 // an instantiation.
7459 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7460 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007461
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007462 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007463 case Unevaluated:
7464 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7465 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007466
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007467 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7468 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7469 // "used"; handle this below.
7470 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007471
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007472 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7473 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7474 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7475 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007476 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007477 return;
7478 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007479
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007480 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007481 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007482 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007483 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7484 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7485 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007486 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007487 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007488 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7489 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7490 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007491
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007492 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007493 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7494 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7495 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007496 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7497 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007498 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7499 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7500 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7501 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007502 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007503 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7504 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007505 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007506 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007507 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007508 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007509 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007510 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7511 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7512 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7513 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7514 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007515 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007516 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007517 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007518 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007519 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7520 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7521 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007522 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007523 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007524 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7525 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007526
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007527 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7528 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7529 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7530 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7531 Loc));
7532 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007533 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007534 Loc));
7535 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007536 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007537
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007538 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007539 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007540
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007541 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007542 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007543
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007544 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007545 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007546 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007547 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7548 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7549 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7550 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7551 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7552 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7553 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7554 }
7555 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007556
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007557 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007558
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007559 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007560 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007561 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007562}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007563
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007564namespace {
7565 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
7566 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
7567 // of when we're entering
7568 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7569 Sema &S;
7570 SourceLocation Loc;
7571
7572 public:
7573 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
7574
7575 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
7576
7577 bool VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7578 bool VisitRecordType(RecordType *T);
7579 };
7580}
7581
7582bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
7583 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7584 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7585 }
7586
7587 return Inherited::VisitTemplateArgument(Arg);
7588}
7589
7590bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitRecordType(RecordType *T) {
7591 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7592 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7593 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7594 return VisitTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7595 Args.flat_size());
7596 }
7597
7598 return false;
7599}
7600
7601void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7602 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
7603 Marker.Visit(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
7604}
7605
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007606/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7607/// of the program being compiled.
7608///
7609/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007610/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007611/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7612/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7613/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7614/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007615/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007616/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007617///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007618/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7619/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7620/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7621/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007622bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007623 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7624 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7625 case Unevaluated:
7626 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7627 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007628
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007629 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7630 Diag(Loc, PD);
7631 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007632
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007633 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7634 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7635 break;
7636 }
7637
7638 return false;
7639}
7640
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007641bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7642 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7643 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7644 return false;
7645
7646 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7647 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7648 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7649 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007650
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007651 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007652 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007653 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7654 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007655 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007656 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7657 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7658 return true;
7659
7660 return false;
7661}
7662
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007663// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7664// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7665void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7666 SourceLocation Loc;
7667
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007668 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7669
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007670 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7671 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7672 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7673 return;
7674
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007675 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7676 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7677 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7678 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7679
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007680 // self = [<foo> init...]
7681 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7682 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7683 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7684
7685 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7686 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7687 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7688 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7689 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007690
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007691 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7692 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7693 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7694 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7695 return;
7696
7697 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7698 } else {
7699 // Not an assignment.
7700 return;
7701 }
7702
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007703 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007704 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007705
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007706 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007707 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007708 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007709 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7710 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7711 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007712}
7713
7714bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7715 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7716
7717 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007718 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007719
7720 QualType T = E->getType();
7721
7722 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7723 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7724 return true;
7725 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7726 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7727 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7728 return true;
7729 }
7730 }
7731
7732 return false;
7733}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007734
7735Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7736 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007737 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7738 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007739 return ExprError();
7740
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007741 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7742 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7743 return ExprError();
7744 }
7745
7746 return Owned(Sub);
7747}